root/include/net/mac80211.h
/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
/*
 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
 *
 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
 * Copyright 2006-2007  Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
 * Copyright 2007-2010  Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
 * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2026 Intel Corporation
 */

#ifndef MAC80211_H
#define MAC80211_H

#include <linux/bug.h>
#include <linux/kernel.h>
#include <linux/if_ether.h>
#include <linux/skbuff.h>
#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
#include <linux/lockdep.h>
#include <net/cfg80211.h>
#include <net/codel.h>
#include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
#include <linux/unaligned.h>

/**
 * DOC: Introduction
 *
 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
 * drivers.
 */

/**
 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
 *
 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
 * tasklet function.
 *
 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
 *       use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
 */

/**
 * DOC: Warning
 *
 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
 */

/**
 * DOC: Frame format
 *
 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
 * hardware.
 *
 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
 *
 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
 *
 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
 */

/**
 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
 *
 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
 *
 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
 * suspend.
 *
 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
 *
 */

/**
 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
 *
 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
 * different stations/interfaces.
 *
 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
 * handler.
 *
 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
 *
 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
 *
 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
 * driver op.
 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
 *
 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
 * ieee80211_return_txq().
 *
 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
 * .release_buffered_frames().
 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
 */

/**
 * DOC: HW timestamping
 *
 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
 *
 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
 *
 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
 */
struct device;

/**
 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
 *
 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
 */
enum ieee80211_max_queues {
        IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =          16,
        IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =       BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
};

#define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE        0xff

/**
 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 */
enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
        IEEE80211_AC_VO         = 0,
        IEEE80211_AC_VI         = 1,
        IEEE80211_AC_BE         = 2,
        IEEE80211_AC_BK         = 3,
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 *
 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 *
 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 *      2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
 */
struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
        u16 txop;
        u16 cw_min;
        u16 cw_max;
        u8 aifs;
        bool acm;
        bool uapsd;
        bool mu_edca;
        struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
};

struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
        unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
        unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
        unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
        unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
 *      this is used only with channel switching with CSA
 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
 *      bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
 *      was changed.
 */
enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
        IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH          = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS      = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR          = BIT(2),
        IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL        = BIT(3),
        IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF        = BIT(4),
        IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP             = BIT(5),
        IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING     = BIT(6),
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
 *      (otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
 */
struct ieee80211_chan_req {
        struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
        struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
 *
 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
 *
 * @def: the channel definition
 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
 *      for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
 * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
 *      active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
 *      after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
 *      this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 *      sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 */
struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
        struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
        struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
        struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;

        int radio_idx;
        u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;

        bool radar_enabled;

        u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
 *      exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
 *      needs to be switched from one to the other.
 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
 *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
 *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
 *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
 *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
 *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
 *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
 *      for changes/removal.)
 */
enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
        CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
        CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
 *
 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
 * done.
 *
 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
 */
struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
        struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
        struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
        struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
        struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 *
 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
 *
 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 *      also implies a change in the AID.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 *      reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 *      new beacon (beaconing modes)
 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 *      enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 *      that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
 *      changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
 *      currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
 *      note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
 *      context had been assigned.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
 *      keep alive) changed.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
 *      functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 *      status changed.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
 * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
 */
enum ieee80211_bss_change {
        BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC               = 1<<0,
        BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT        = 1<<1,
        BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE        = 1<<2,
        BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT            = 1<<3,
        BSS_CHANGED_HT                  = 1<<4,
        BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES         = 1<<5,
        BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT          = 1<<6,
        BSS_CHANGED_BSSID               = 1<<7,
        BSS_CHANGED_BEACON              = 1<<8,
        BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED      = 1<<9,
        BSS_CHANGED_CQM                 = 1<<10,
        BSS_CHANGED_IBSS                = 1<<11,
        BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER          = 1<<12,
        BSS_CHANGED_QOS                 = 1<<13,
        BSS_CHANGED_IDLE                = 1<<14,
        BSS_CHANGED_SSID                = 1<<15,
        BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP       = 1<<16,
        BSS_CHANGED_PS                  = 1<<17,
        BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER             = 1<<18,
        BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS              = 1<<19,
        BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO         = 1<<20,
        BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH           = 1<<21,
        BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
        BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS           = 1<<23,
        BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE          = 1<<24,
        BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE          = 1<<25,
        BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER       = 1<<26,
        BSS_CHANGED_TWT                 = 1<<27,
        BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD          = 1<<28,
        BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR        = 1<<29,
        BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
        BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
        BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS     = BIT_ULL(33),
        BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM            = BIT_ULL(34),
        BSS_CHANGED_TPE                 = BIT_ULL(35),

        /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
};

/*
 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 * filtering will be disabled.
 */
#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4

/**
 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
 *      they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
 *      once each time the timeout triggers.
 */
enum ieee80211_event_type {
        RSSI_EVENT,
        MLME_EVENT,
        BAR_RX_EVENT,
        BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
 */
enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
        RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
        RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
 */
struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
        enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
 */
enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
        AUTH_EVENT,
        ASSOC_EVENT,
        DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
        DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
 */
enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
        MLME_SUCCESS,
        MLME_DENIED,
        MLME_TIMEOUT,
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
 */
struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
        enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
        enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
        u16 reason;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
 * @tid: the tid
 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
 */
struct ieee80211_ba_event {
        struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
        u16 tid;
        u16 ssn;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
 * @u:union holding the fields above
 */
struct ieee80211_event {
        enum ieee80211_event_type type;
        union {
                struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
                struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
                struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
        } u;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
 *
 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
 *
 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 */
struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
        u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
        u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
 *
 * @lci: LCI subelement content
 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
 * @lci_len: LCI data length
 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
 */
struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
        const u8 *lci;
        const u8 *civicloc;
        size_t lci_len;
        size_t civicloc_len;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
 *
 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 */
struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
        u32 min_interval;
        u32 max_interval;
};

#define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ       5
struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
        bool valid;
        s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
        u8 count;
};

#define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ        16
struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
        bool valid;
        s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
        u8 count, n;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
 * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
 *      (indexed by TX power category)
 * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
 *      160, 320 MHz each
 *      (indexed by TX power category)
 * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
 *      subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
 *      (indexed by TX power category)
 * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
 *      each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
 *      (indexed by TX power category)
 */
struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
        struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
        struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 *
 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 *
 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
 *      when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
 *      necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
 *      responses.
 * @addr: (link) address used locally
 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 *      mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 *      mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 *      valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
 *      with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
 *      as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
 *      HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
 *      only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
 *      association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
 *      %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
 *      the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
 *      (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
 *      is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
 *      IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
 *      by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
 *      guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
 *      Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
 *      know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 *      index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 *      the current band.
 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 *      configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
 *      This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
 *      Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
 *      be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 *      implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
 *      cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
 *      relation to the newly configured threshold.
 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
 *      implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
 *      threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
 * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
 *      Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
 *      TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
 *      NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
 *      userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
 *      NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
 *      to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
 *      if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
 *      transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
 *      In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
 *      a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
 *      protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
 *      station.
 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
 *      responder functionality.
 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
 * @tx_bss_conf: Pointer to the BSS configuration of transmitting interface
 *      if MBSSID is enabled. This pointer is RCU-protected due to CSA finish
 *      and BSS color change flows accessing it.
 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
 *      nontransmitted BSSIDs
 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
 *      in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
 *      connected to (STA)
 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 *      interval.
 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
 *      to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
 * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
 * @epcs_support: does this BSS support EPCS
 * @uhr_support: does this BSS support UHR
 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
 *      when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
 *      path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
 *      be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
 *      processed after it switches back to %NULL.
 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
 *      beamformer
 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
 *      beamformee
 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
 *      beamformer
 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
 *      beamformee
 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
 *      beamformer
 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
 *      beamformee
 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
 *      beamformer
 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
 *      (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
 *      bandwidth
 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
 *      beamformer
 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
 *      beamformee
 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
 *      beamformer
 * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
 *      reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
 *      bandwidth
 * @eht_disable_mcs15: disable EHT-MCS 15 reception capability.
 * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
 *      information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
 *      beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
 * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
 *      that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
 *      its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
 *      link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
 *      bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
 *      link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
 *      In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
 *      be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
 *      the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
 *      (as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
 * @s1g_long_beacon_period: number of beacon intervals between each long
 *      beacon transmission.
 */
struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
        struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
        struct cfg80211_bss *bss;

        const u8 *bssid;
        unsigned int link_id;
        u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
        u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
        bool uora_exists;
        u8 uora_ocw_range;
        u16 frame_time_rts_th;
        bool he_support;
        bool twt_requester;
        bool twt_responder;
        bool twt_protected;
        bool twt_broadcast;
        /* erp related data */
        bool use_cts_prot;
        bool use_short_preamble;
        bool use_short_slot;
        bool enable_beacon;
        u8 dtim_period;
        u16 beacon_int;
        u16 assoc_capability;
        u64 sync_tsf;
        u32 sync_device_ts;
        u8 sync_dtim_count;
        u32 basic_rates;
        struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
        int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
        u16 ht_operation_mode;
        s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
        u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
        s32 cqm_rssi_low;
        s32 cqm_rssi_high;
        struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
        struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
        bool qos;
        bool hidden_ssid;
        int txpower;
        enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
        struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
        bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
        u16 max_idle_period;
        bool protected_keep_alive;
        bool ftm_responder;
        struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
        /* Multiple BSSID data */
        bool nontransmitted;
        struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *tx_bss_conf;
        u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
        u8 bssid_index;
        u8 bssid_indicator;
        bool ema_ap;
        u8 profile_periodicity;
        struct {
                u32 params;
                u16 nss_set;
        } he_oper;
        struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
        struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
        struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
        u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
        struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
        enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;

        struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;

        u8 pwr_reduction;
        bool eht_support;
        bool epcs_support;
        bool uhr_support;

        bool csa_active;

        bool mu_mimo_owner;
        struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;

        bool color_change_active;
        u8 color_change_color;

        bool ht_ldpc;
        bool vht_ldpc;
        bool he_ldpc;
        bool vht_su_beamformer;
        bool vht_su_beamformee;
        bool vht_mu_beamformer;
        bool vht_mu_beamformee;
        bool he_su_beamformer;
        bool he_su_beamformee;
        bool he_mu_beamformer;
        bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
        bool eht_su_beamformer;
        bool eht_su_beamformee;
        bool eht_mu_beamformer;
        bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
        bool eht_disable_mcs15;

        u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
        u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;

        u8 s1g_long_beacon_period;
};

/**
 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 *
 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 *      number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 *      number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 *      IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 *      assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 *      for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 *      that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 *      If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 *      assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 *      802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 *      beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 *      station
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 *      because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 *      avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 *      firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 *      went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 *      the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 *      that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 *      since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 *      hardware queue.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 *      is for the whole aggregation.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 *      so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 *      set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 *      be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
 *      that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
 *      off-channel operation.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
 *      (header conversion)
 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 *      used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 *      used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
 *      frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
 *      be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 *      transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 *      by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 *      queue gets full.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 *      after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 *      be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
 *      code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
 *      should kick the MLME state machine.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 *      MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 *      status to user space)
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 *      frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 *      the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 *      in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 *      handled properly by the device.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 *      testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 *      TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
 *      This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
 *      frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
 *      when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
 *      an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
 *      the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
 *      PS-Poll responses.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
 *      This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
 *      the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
 *      would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
 *      monitor injection).
 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
 *      IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
 *      any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
 *      This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
 *      behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
 *
 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 *       forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 */
enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS          = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ             = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK                 = BIT(2),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT          = BIT(3),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT         = BIT(4),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM        = BIT(5),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU                  = BIT(6),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED               = BIT(7),
        IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED           = BIT(8),
        IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK                   = BIT(9),
        IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU                 = BIT(10),
        IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK         = BIT(11),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE        = BIT(12),
        IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK        = BIT(13),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP         = BIT(14),
        IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED              = BIT(15),
        IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT         = BIT(16),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER           = BIT(17),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES            = BIT(18),
        IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION       = BIT(19),
        IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX         = BIT(20),
        IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX     = BIT(21),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC                   = BIT(22),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC                   = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN             = BIT(25),
        IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE     = BIT(26),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE            = BIT(27),
        IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP                = BIT(28),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE            = BIT(29),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG               = BIT(30),
        IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED     = BIT(31),
};

#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT             23

#define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS

/**
 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
 *
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
 *      protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
 *      frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 *      used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 *      it can be sent out.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
 *      has already been assigned to this frame.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
 *      relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
 *      of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
 *      for sequence number assignment
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
 *      which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
 *      operation on the interface.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
 *      frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
 *      only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
 *      also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
 *      is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
 *      it's intended for an MLD.
 *
 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
 */
enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO       = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE           = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT           = BIT(2),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU                 = BIT(3),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT             = BIT(4),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP     = BIT(5),
        IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING   = BIT(6),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO              = BIT(7),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER          = BIT(8),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX    = BIT(9),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK    = BIT(10),
        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK              = 0xf0000000,
};

#define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED      0xf
#define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC       \
        u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
                        IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)

/**
 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
 *
 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
 *
 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
 */
enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
        IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
};

/*
 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
 */
#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |               \
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |           \
        IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |               \
        IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |           \
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |                \
        IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)

/**
 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
 *      Rate Control algorithm.
 *
 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
 *      This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
 *      into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
 *      Greenfield mode.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
 *      (80+80 isn't supported yet)
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
 *      adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
 *      NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
 */
enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS             = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT         = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE      = BIT(2),

        /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS                     = BIT(3),
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD             = BIT(4),
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH            = BIT(5),
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA                = BIT(6),
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI                = BIT(7),
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS                 = BIT(8),
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH            = BIT(9),
        IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH           = BIT(10),
};


/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40

/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24

/* maximum number of rate stages */
#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES  4

/* maximum number of rate table entries */
#define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE    4

/**
 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
 *
 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
 *
 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
 *
 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
 *
 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
 * information::
 *
 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
 *
 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
 * information should then contain::
 *
 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
 *
 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
 */
struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
        s8 idx;
        u16 count:5,
            flags:11;
} __packed;

#define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY          31

static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
{
        return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
}

static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
                                          u8 mcs, u8 nss)
{
        WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
        WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
        rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
}

static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
{
        return rate->idx & 0xF;
}

static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
{
        return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
}

/**
 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
 *
 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
 *
 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
 *      not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
 *      link the frame will be transmitted on
 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
 *      see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
 * @control: union part for control data
 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
 * @pad: padding
 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
 * @status: union part for status data
 * @status.rates: attempted rates
 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
 *      used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
 */
struct ieee80211_tx_info {
        /* common information */
        u32 flags;
        u32 band:3,
            status_data_idr:1,
            status_data:13,
            hw_queue:4,
            tx_time_est:10;
        /* 1 free bit */

        union {
                struct {
                        union {
                                /* rate control */
                                struct {
                                        struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
                                                IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
                                        s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
                                        u8 use_rts:1;
                                        u8 use_cts_prot:1;
                                        u8 short_preamble:1;
                                        u8 skip_table:1;

                                        /* for injection only (bitmap) */
                                        u8 antennas:2;

                                        /* 14 bits free */
                                };
                                /* only needed before rate control */
                                unsigned long jiffies;
                        };
                        /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
                        struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
                        struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
                        u32 flags;
                        codel_time_t enqueue_time;
                } control;
                struct {
                        u64 cookie;
                } ack;
                struct {
                        struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
                        s32 ack_signal;
                        u8 ampdu_ack_len;
                        u8 ampdu_len;
                        u8 antenna;
                        u8 pad;
                        u16 tx_time;
                        u8 flags;
                        u8 pad2;
                        void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
                } status;
                struct {
                        struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
                                IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
                        u8 pad[4];

                        void *rate_driver_data[
                                IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
                };
                void *driver_data[
                        IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
        };
};

static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
{
        /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
         * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
         */
        info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
        return info->tx_time_est << 2;
}

static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
{
        return info->tx_time_est << 2;
}

/***
 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
 *
 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
 *
 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
 *      corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
 *      that was used when sending the packet.
 */
struct ieee80211_rate_status {
        struct rate_info rate_idx;
        u8 try_count;
        u8 tx_power_idx;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
 *
 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
 * @info: Basic tx status information
 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
 *      Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
 *      frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
 */
struct ieee80211_tx_status {
        struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
        struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
        struct sk_buff *skb;
        struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
        ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
        u8 n_rates;

        struct list_head *free_list;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
 *
 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
 *
 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
 */
struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
        const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
        size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
        const u8 *common_ies;
        size_t common_ie_len;
};


static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
{
        return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
}

static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
{
        return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
}

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
 *
 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
 *
 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
 *
 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
 *       driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
 *       any fields it needs after calling this helper.
 */
static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
{
        int i;

        BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
                     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
        BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
                     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
        BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
        /* clear the rate counts */
        for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
                info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
        memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
}


/**
 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
 *
 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
 *      Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
 *      verification has been done by the hardware.
 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
 *      If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
 *      hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
 *      flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
 *      Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
 *      is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
 *      de-duplication by itself.
 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
 *      the frame.
 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
 *      the frame.
 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
 *      field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
 *      where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
 *      field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
 *      was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
 *      merging.
 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
 *      field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
 *      (including FCS) was received.
 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
 *      field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
 *      is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
 *      @mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
 *      %RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
 *      reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
 *      Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
 *      number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
 *      each A-MPDU
 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
 *      subframes of a single A-MPDU
 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
 *      on this subframe
 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
 *      done by the hardware
 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
 *      processing it in any regular way.
 *      This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
 *      them for sniffing purposes.
 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
 *      monitor interfaces.
 *      This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
 *      them for sniffing purposes.
 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
 *      subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
 *      All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
 *      if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
 *      the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
 *      deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
 *      subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
 *      either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
 *      interleaved with other frames.
 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
 *      skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
 *      If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
 *      to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
 *      data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
 *      in the skb.
 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
 *      This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
 *      the first subframe.
 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
 *      be done in the hardware.
 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
 *      frame
 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
 *      (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
 *      
 *       - DATA3_DATA_MCS
 *       - DATA3_DATA_DCM
 *       - DATA3_CODING
 *       - DATA5_GI
 *       - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
 *       - DATA6_NSTS
 *       - DATA3_STBC
 *      
 *      from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
 *      (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
 *      the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
 *      in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
 *      known the frame shouldn't be reported.
 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
 *      hardware or driver)
 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT: VHT radiotap data is present
 */
enum mac80211_rx_flags {
        RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR              = BIT(0),
        RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED               = BIT(1),
        RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR            = BIT(2),
        RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED           = BIT(3),
        RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED             = BIT(4),
        RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC          = BIT(5),
        RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC         = BIT(6),
        RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64    = BIT(7),
        RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL           = BIT(8),
        RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS           = BIT(9),
        RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED            = BIT(10),
        RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED           = BIT(11),
        RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN        = BIT(12),
        RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST           = BIT(13),
        RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR   = BIT(14),
        /* one free bit at 15 */
        RX_FLAG_MACTIME                 = BIT(16) | BIT(17),
        RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START      = 1 << 16,
        RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START           = 2 << 16,
        RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END             = 3 << 16,
        RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR            = BIT(18),
        RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE              = BIT(19),
        RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END     = BIT(20),
        RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED            = BIT(21),
        RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN           = BIT(22),
        RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED            = BIT(23),
        RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT           = BIT(24),
        RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN     = BIT(25),
        RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE             = BIT(26),
        RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU          = BIT(27),
        RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG           = BIT(28),
        RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU                 = BIT(29),
        RX_FLAG_8023                    = BIT(30),
        RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT            = BIT(31),
};

/**
 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
 *
 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
 *      if the driver fills this value it should add
 *      %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
 *      to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
 */
enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
        RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE            = BIT(0),
        RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI            = BIT(2),
        RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF               = BIT(3),
        RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK           = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
        RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC                = BIT(6),
        RX_ENC_FLAG_BF                  = BIT(7),
};

#define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT          4

enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
        RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
        RX_ENC_HT,
        RX_ENC_VHT,
        RX_ENC_HE,
        RX_ENC_EHT,
        RX_ENC_UHR,
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
 *
 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
 *
 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
 *      (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
 *      needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
 *      needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
 *      Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
 *      it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
 *      This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
 *      for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
 *      unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
 *      @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
 *      values were filled.
 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
 *      support dB or unspecified units)
 * @antenna: antenna used
 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
 *      HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE, EHT and UHR only)
 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
 * @uhr: UHR specific rate information
 * @uhr.ru: UHR RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
 * @uhr.gi: UHR GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
 * @uhr.elr: UHR ELR MCS was used
 * @uhr.im: UHR interference mitigation was used
 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
 *      each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
 *      is set only when connection is MLO.
 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
 *      @link_valid.
 */
struct ieee80211_rx_status {
        u64 mactime;
        union {
                u64 boottime_ns;
                ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
        };
        u32 device_timestamp;
        u32 ampdu_reference;
        u32 flag;
        u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
        u8 enc_flags;
        u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
        union {
                struct {
                        u8 he_ru:3;
                        u8 he_gi:2;
                        u8 he_dcm:1;
                };
                struct {
                        u8 ru:4;
                        u8 gi:2;
                } eht;
                struct {
                        u8 ru:4;
                        u8 gi:2;
                        u8 elr:1;
                        u8 im:1;
                } uhr;
        };
        u8 rate_idx;
        u8 nss;
        u8 rx_flags;
        u8 band;
        u8 antenna;
        s8 signal;
        u8 chains;
        s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
        u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
        u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
};

static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
{
        return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
               (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
}

/**
 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
 *
 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
 *
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
 *      to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
 *      or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
 *      This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
 *      meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
 *      transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
 *      Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
 *      driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
 *      for more.
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
 *      the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
 *      may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
 *      be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
 *      it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
 *      operating channel.
 */
enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
        IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR          = (1<<0),
        IEEE80211_CONF_PS               = (1<<1),
        IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE             = (1<<2),
        IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL       = (1<<3),
};


/**
 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
 *
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
 *      Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
 *      otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
 */
enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
        IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS              = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL   = BIT(2),
        IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR           = BIT(3),
        IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS                = BIT(4),
        IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER             = BIT(5),
        IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL           = BIT(6),
        IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS      = BIT(7),
        IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE              = BIT(8),
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
 *
 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
 */
enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
        IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
        IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
        IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
        IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,

        /* keep last */
        IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
 *
 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
 *
 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
 *
 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
 *      in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
 *      has been received and the DTIM period is known.
 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
 *      powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
 *      the CONF_PS flag is set.
 *
 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
 *      value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
 *
 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
 *
 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
 *      (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
 *      but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
 *      frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
 *      number of transmissions not the number of retries
 *
 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
 *      %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
 *      configured for an HT channel.
 *      Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
 *      otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
 */
struct ieee80211_conf {
        u32 flags;
        int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;

        u16 listen_interval;
        u8 ps_dtim_period;

        u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;

        struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
        bool radar_enabled;
        enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
 *
 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
 * operation.
 *
 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
 *      Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
 *      announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
 *      the driver passed into mac80211.
 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
 *      rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
 *      scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
 *      current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
 *      channel, expressed in TU.
 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
 */
struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
        u64 timestamp;
        u32 device_timestamp;
        bool block_tx;
        struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
        u8 count;
        u8 link_id;
        u32 delay;
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
 *
 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
 *      on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
 *      monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
 *      connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
 *      provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
 *      interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
 *      but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
 *      only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
 *      and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
 *      this is not pure P2P vif.
 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
 *      enabled for the interface.
 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
 *      operation on this interface and request a channel context without
 *      the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
 *      handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
 * @IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC: indicates that the AP sta should
 *      be removed only after setting the vif as unassociated, and not the
 *      opposite. Only relevant for STA vifs.
 */
enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
        IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER             = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI         = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD            = BIT(2),
        IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE            = BIT(3),
        IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE                = BIT(4),
        IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW     = BIT(5),
        IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC  = BIT(6),
};


/**
 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
 *
 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
 *      The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
 *      It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
 *      The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
 *      mac80211.
 */

enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
        IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED         = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR           = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED         = BIT(2),
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_eml_params - EHT Operating mode notification parameters
 *
 * EML Operating mode notification parameters received in the Operating mode
 * notification frame. This struct is used as a container to pass the info to
 * the underlay driver.
 *
 * @link_id: the link ID where the Operating mode notification frame has been
 *      received.
 * @control: EML control field defined in P802.11be section 9.4.1.76.
 * @link_bitmap: eMLSR/eMLMR enabled links defined in P802.11be
 *      section 9.4.1.76.
 * @emlmr_mcs_map_count: eMLMR number of valid mcs_map_bw fields according to
 *      P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
 * @emlmr_mcs_map_bw: eMLMR supported MCS and NSS set subfileds defined in
 *      P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
 */
struct ieee80211_eml_params {
        u8 link_id;
        u8 control;
        u16 link_bitmap;
        u8 emlmr_mcs_map_count;
        u8 emlmr_mcs_map_bw[9];
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
 * @assoc: association status
 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
 *      offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
 *      P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
 *      Figure 9-1001k
 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
 *      may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
 *      The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
 *      to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
 *      may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
 *      array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
 *      hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
 *      your driver/device needs to do.
 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
 *      (station mode only)
 */
struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
        /* association related data */
        bool assoc, ibss_joined;
        bool ibss_creator;
        bool ps;
        u16 aid;
        u16 eml_cap;
        u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
        u16 mld_capa_op;

        __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
        int arp_addr_cnt;
        u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
        size_t ssid_len;
        bool s1g;
        bool idle;
        u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
};

#define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8

/**
 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
 *
 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
 *      this TID is not included.
 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
 *      TID is not included.
 * @valid: info is valid or not.
 */
struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
        u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
        u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
        bool valid;
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
 */
enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
        NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
        NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
        NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
 *
 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
 *
 * @type: type of this virtual interface
 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
 *      or the BSS we're associated to
 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
 *      indexed by link ID
 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
 *      The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
 *      API calls meant for that purpose.
 * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
 *      due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
 *      0 for non-MLO.
 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
 *      suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
 *      future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
 *      0 for non-MLO.
 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
 *      see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
 * @addr: address of this interface
 * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
 *      passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
 *      interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
 *      vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
 *      can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
 *      for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
 *      these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
 *      or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
 *      at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
 *      These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
 *      .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
 *      within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
 *      restrictions.
 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
 *      interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
 *      monitor interface (if that is requested.)
 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
 *      interface.
 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
 *      for this interface.
 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 *      sizeof(void \*).
 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
 *      &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
 */
struct ieee80211_vif {
        enum nl80211_iftype type;
        struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
        struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
        struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
        u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
        struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
        u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
        bool addr_valid;
        bool p2p;

        u8 cab_queue;
        u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];

        struct ieee80211_txq *txq;

        netdev_features_t netdev_features;
        u32 driver_flags;
        u32 offload_flags;

#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
        struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
#endif

        bool probe_req_reg;
        bool rx_mcast_action_reg;

        /* must be last */
        u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
};

/**
 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
 * Return: the usable link bitmap
 */
static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
{
        return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
}

/**
 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
 * @vif: the vif
 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
 */
static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
{
        /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
        return vif->valid_links != 0;
}

/**
 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
 * @vif: the vif
 * @link_id: the link ID to check
 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
 *      the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
 */
static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                             unsigned int link_id)
{
        if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
                return link_id == 0;
        return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
}

#define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)                            \
        for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)    \
                if ((!(vif)->active_links ||                                    \
                     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&                     \
                    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))

static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
{
#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
        return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
#endif
        return false;
}

/**
 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
 *
 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
 *
 * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
 */
struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);

/**
 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
 *
 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
 *
 * Return: pointer to the wdev
 */
struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
{
        return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
}

#define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)           \
        rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],    \
                                  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))

#define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)               \
        rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],        \
                              lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))

/**
 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
 *
 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
 *      driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
 *      particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
 *      will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
 *      the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
 *      generation in software.
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
 *      that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
 *      CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
 *      (MFP) to be done in software.
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
 *      if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
 *      itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
 *      @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
 *      not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
 *      MIC.
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
 *      management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
 *      crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
 *      properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
 *      fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
 *      RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
 *      %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
 *      driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
 *      only for management frames (MFP).
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
 *      driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
 *      be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
 *      a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
 *      @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
 *      for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
 *      number generation only
 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
 *      (set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
 */
enum ieee80211_key_flags {
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT     = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV          = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC        = BIT(2),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE             = BIT(3),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX           = BIT(4),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE         = BIT(5),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT              = BIT(6),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM     = BIT(7),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE        = BIT(8),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX           = BIT(9),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE        = BIT(10),
        IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU            = BIT(11),
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
 *
 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
 *
 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
 *      wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
 *      encrypted in hardware.
 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
 *      needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
 * @keyidx: the key index (0-7)
 * @keylen: key material length
 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
 *      data block:
 *      - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
 *      - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
 *      - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
 * @link_id: the link ID, 0 for non-MLO, or -1 for pairwise keys
 */
struct ieee80211_key_conf {
        atomic64_t tx_pn;
        u32 cipher;
        u8 icv_len;
        u8 iv_len;
        u8 hw_key_idx;
        s8 keyidx;
        u16 flags;
        s8 link_id;
        u8 keylen;
        u8 key[];
};

#define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN    16

#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))

/**
 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
 *
 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
 *      reverse order than in packet)
 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
 *      reverse order than in packet)
 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
 *      reverse order than in packet)
 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
 *      reverse order than in packet)
 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
 */
struct ieee80211_key_seq {
        union {
                struct {
                        u32 iv32;
                        u16 iv16;
                } tkip;
                struct {
                        u8 pn[6];
                } ccmp;
                struct {
                        u8 pn[6];
                } aes_cmac;
                struct {
                        u8 pn[6];
                } aes_gmac;
                struct {
                        u8 pn[6];
                } gcmp;
                struct {
                        u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
                        u8 seq_len;
                } hw;
        };
};

/**
 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
 *
 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
 *
 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
 */
enum set_key_cmd {
        SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
 *
 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
 *      this is a special state for add/remove transitions
 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
 */
enum ieee80211_sta_state {
        /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
        IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
        IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
        IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
        IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
        IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
 *      (including 80+80 MHz)
 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
 *
 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
 *      correctly, the values must be sorted.
 */
enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
        IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
        IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
        IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
        IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
        IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
};

#define IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_MAX IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320

/**
 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
 *
 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
 *      Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
 */
struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
        struct rcu_head rcu_head;
        struct {
                s8 idx;
                u8 count;
                u8 count_cts;
                u8 count_rts;
                u16 flags;
        } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
 *
 * Used to configure txpower for station.
 *
 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
 *      to the STA.
 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
 *      will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
 *      %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
 *      NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
 *      per peer TPC.
 */
struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
        s16 power;
        enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
 *
 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
 *
 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
 *      This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
 *      For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
 *
 *      * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
 *        A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
 *      * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
 *        size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
 *
 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
 */
struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
        u16 max_amsdu_len;

        u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
        u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
 *
 * @sta: reference to owning STA
 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
 *      in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
 *      from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
 * @uhr_cap: UHR capabilities of this STA
 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities of this STA
 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
 *      station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
 *      notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
 *      the station moves to associated state.
 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
 *
 */
struct ieee80211_link_sta {
        struct ieee80211_sta *sta;

        u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
        u8 link_id;
        enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;

        u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
        struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
        struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
        struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
        struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
        struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
        struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap uhr_cap;
        struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;

        struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;

        u8 rx_nss;
        enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
        struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
 *
 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
 *
 * @addr: MAC address
 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
 *      that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
 *      Can be modified by driver.
 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
 *      otherwise always false)
 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 *      sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
 *      if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
 *      IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
 * @rates: rate control selection table
 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
 *      valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
 *      A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
 *      unlimited.
 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities of this MLO station
 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
 *      For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
 *      ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
 *      is used for non-data frames
 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
 *      specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
 *      link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
 *      the first added link STA will point to deflink.
 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
 *      i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
 *      would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
 *      STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
 *      @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
 *      would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
 *      by the AP.
 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
 * @epp_peer: indicates that the peer is an EPP peer.
 */
struct ieee80211_sta {
        u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
        u16 aid;
        u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
        bool wme;
        u8 uapsd_queues;
        u8 max_sp;
        struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
        bool tdls;
        bool tdls_initiator;
        bool mfp;
        bool mlo;
        bool spp_amsdu;
        u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
        u16 eml_cap;

        struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;

        bool support_p2p_ps;

        struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];

        u16 valid_links;
        bool epp_peer;
        struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
        struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];

        /* must be last */
        u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
};

#ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
#else
static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
{
        return true;
}
#endif

#define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)            \
        rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],         \
                                  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))

#define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)                \
        rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],             \
                              lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))

#define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)                   \
        for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)         \
                if ((!(vif)->active_links ||                                    \
                     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&                     \
                    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))

/**
 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
 *
 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
 *
 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
 */
enum sta_notify_cmd {
        STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
 *
 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
 *      it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
 */
struct ieee80211_tx_control {
        struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
 *      %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
 * @ac: the AC for this queue
 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
 *
 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
 */
struct ieee80211_txq {
        struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
        struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
        u8 tid;
        u8 ac;

        /* must be last */
        u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
 *
 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
 *      The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
 *      controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
 *      should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
 *      will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
 *      algorithm.
 *      Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
 *      callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
 *      the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
 *      @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
 *      timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
 *      CCK frames.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
 *      Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
 *      the FCS at the end.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
 *      Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
 *      for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
 *      rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
 *      to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
 *      multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
 *      the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
 *      Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
 *      expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
 *      If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
 *      Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
 *      one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
 *      between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
 *      Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
 *      Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
 *      Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
 *      Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
 *      Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
 *      stack support for dynamic PS.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
 *      Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
 *      Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
 *      Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
 *      the stack.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
 *      The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
 *      periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
 *      This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
 *      dtim_period).
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
 *      per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
 *      the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
 *      to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
 *      possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
 *      only in that case.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
 *      autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
 *      this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
 *      stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
 *      Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
 *      the PS mode of connected stations.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
 *      setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
 *      software.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
 *      a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
 *      active interfaces.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
 *      of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
 *      This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
 *      channels.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
 *      be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
 *      desired (and thus have them named as desired).
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
 *      crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
 *      try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
 *      the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
 *      supported cipher suites.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
 *      this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
 *      for frames.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
 *      queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
 *      for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
 *      control for more details.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
 *      selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
 *      P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
 *      is supported.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
 *      only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
 *      and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
 *      using aggregation for such frames.)
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
 *      for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
 *      is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
 *      CSA frame.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
 *      or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
 *      in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
 *      than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
 *      within A-MPDU.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
 *      for sent beacons.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
 *      station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
 *      by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
 *      from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
 *      reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
 *      order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
 *      timeout.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
 *      which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
 *      A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
 *      When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
 *      limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
 *      max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
 *      skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
 *      by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
 *      drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
 *      is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
 *      The stack will not do fragmentation.
 *      The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
 *      TDLS links.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
 *      support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
 *      course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
 *      extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
 *      the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
 *      but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
 *      See also the documentation for that flag.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
 *      MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
 *      TXQs to start with.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
 *      length in tx status information
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
 *      only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
 *      aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
 *      A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
 *      offload
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
 *      offload
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
 *      decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
 *      If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
 *      usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
 *      the stack.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
 *      collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
 *      multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
 *      and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
 *      no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
 *      implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
 *      link is switching.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
 *      but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
 *      HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
 *      testing.
 *
 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
 */
enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
        IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
        IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
        IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
        IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
        IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
        IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
        IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
        IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
        IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
        IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
        IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
        IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
        IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
        IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
        IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
        IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
        IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
        IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
        IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
        IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
        IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
        IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
        IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
        IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
        IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
        IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
        IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
        IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
        IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
        IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
        IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
        IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
        IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
        IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
        IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
        IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
        IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
        IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
        IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
        IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
        IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,

        /* keep last, obviously */
        NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
 *
 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
 *
 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
 *      802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
 *      members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
 *      and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
 *      bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
 *
 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
 *
 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
 *      along with this structure.
 *
 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
 *
 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
 *      for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
 *
 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
 *      Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
 *
 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
 *      only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
 *
 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
 *      that HW supports
 *
 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
 *      data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
 *      queues need to have configurable access parameters.
 *
 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
 *      If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
 *      set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
 *
 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
 *      within &struct ieee80211_vif.
 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
 *      within &struct ieee80211_sta.
 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
 *      within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
 *      within @struct ieee80211_txq.
 *
 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
 *      can handle.
 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
 *      the hw can report back.
 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
 *
 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
 *      sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
 *      aggregation.
 *      This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
 *      number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
 *      it shouldn't be set.
 *
 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
 *      aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
 *      advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
 *      the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
 *      with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
 *      For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
 *
 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
 *      of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
 *
 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
 *      (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
 *
 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
 *      reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
 *      include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
 *      adding _BW is supported today.
 *
 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
 *      the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
 *      Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
 *
 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
 *      @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
 *      field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
 *      device_timestamp.
 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
 *      IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
 *      IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
 *      radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
 *
 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
 *      from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
 *      other features will be rejected during HW registration.
 *
 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
 *      for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
 *      enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
 *      Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
 *      that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
 *      neither enabled.
 *
 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
 *      deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
 *      Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
 *
 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
 *      device.
 *
 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
 *      them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
 *      unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
 *
 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
 *      refilling deficit of each TXQ.
 *
 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
 *
 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
 *      The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
 *      The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
 *
 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
 */
struct ieee80211_hw {
        struct ieee80211_conf conf;
        struct wiphy *wiphy;
        const char *rate_control_algorithm;
        void *priv;
        unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
        unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
        unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
        int vif_data_size;
        int sta_data_size;
        int chanctx_data_size;
        int txq_data_size;
        u16 queues;
        u16 max_listen_interval;
        s8 max_signal;
        u8 max_rates;
        u8 max_report_rates;
        u8 max_rate_tries;
        u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
        u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
        u8 max_tx_fragments;
        u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
        u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
        u16 radiotap_vht_details;
        struct {
                int units_pos;
                s16 accuracy;
        } radiotap_timestamp;
        netdev_features_t netdev_features;
        u8 uapsd_queues;
        u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
        u8 max_nan_de_entries;
        u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
        u8 weight_multiplier;
        u32 max_mtu;
        const s8 *tx_power_levels;
        u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
};

static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
{
        return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
}
#define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)     _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)

static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
{
        return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
}
#define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)       _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)

/**
 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
 *
 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
 * @req: cfg80211 request.
 */
struct ieee80211_scan_request {
        struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;

        /* Keep last */
        struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
 *
 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
 * @status: channel-switch response status
 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
 */
struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
        struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
        struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
        u8 action_code;
        u32 status;
        u32 timestamp;
        u16 switch_time;
        u16 switch_timeout;
        struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
        u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
};

/**
 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
 *
 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
 *
 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
 * is already used internally by mac80211.
 *
 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
 */
struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);

/**
 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
 *
 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
 */
static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
{
        set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
}

/**
 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
 *
 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
 * @addr: the address to set
 */
static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
{
        memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
}

static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
{
        if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
                return NULL;

        if (c->band >= NUM_NL80211_BANDS)
                return NULL;

        return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
}

static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                           const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
{
        if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
                return NULL;
        return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
}

static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                             const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
{
        if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
                return NULL;
        return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
}

/**
 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
 * @hw: the hardware
 * @skb: the skb
 *
 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
 */
void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);

/**
 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
 * @hw: the hardware
 * @skbs: the skbs
 *
 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
 * relevant locks to use it.
 */
void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct sk_buff_head *skbs);

/**
 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
 *
 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
 *
 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
 *
 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
 *
 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
 *
 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
 *
 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
 *
 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
 * based on the receive flags.
 *
 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
 * keys.
 *
 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
 * handler.
 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
 *
 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
 *
 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
 * requirements:
 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
      once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
   2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
      at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
   3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
      encrypted with the new key when also needing
      @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
   4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
   Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
 */

/**
 * DOC: Powersave support
 *
 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
 *
 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
 * it finds traffic directed to it.
 *
 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
 *
 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
 *
 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
 *
 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
 * periods.
 *
 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
 *
 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
 *
 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
 */

/**
 * DOC: Beacon filter support
 *
 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
 *
 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
 *
 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
 *
 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
 *
 *  - a list of information element IDs
 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
 *
 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
 * vendor information elements.
 *
 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
 *
 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
 *
 *
 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
 *
 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
 * signal strength threshold checking.
 */

/**
 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
 *
 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
 *
 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
 * hardware flags.
 *
 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
 * turned off otherwise.
 *
 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
 */

/**
 * DOC: Frame filtering
 *
 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
 *
 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
 *
 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
 *
 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
 * or dropped.
 *
 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
 * the flag, but not clear it.
 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
 */

/**
 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
 *
 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
 *
 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
 * the driver code.
 *
 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
 *
 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
 * @sta_notify callback.
 *
 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
 *
 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
 *
 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
 *
 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
 *
 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
 *
 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
 *
 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
 */

/**
 * DOC: HW queue control
 *
 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
 * was problematic for a few reasons:
 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
 *
 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
 *
 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
 * the hardware queue.
 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
 *
 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
 *
 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
 * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
 * off-channel queue:         9
 *
 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
 *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
 *
 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
 *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
 *
 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
 *
 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
 */

/**
 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
 *
 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
 *
 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
 *      by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
 *      multicast address.
 *
 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
 *      %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
 *
 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
 *      the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
 *
 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
 *      to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
 *      by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
 *      mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
 *      honour this flag if possible.
 *
 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
 *      station
 *
 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
 *
 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
 *
 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
 *
 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
 */
enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
        FIF_ALLMULTI            = 1<<1,
        FIF_FCSFAIL             = 1<<2,
        FIF_PLCPFAIL            = 1<<3,
        FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
        FIF_CONTROL             = 1<<5,
        FIF_OTHER_BSS           = 1<<6,
        FIF_PSPOLL              = 1<<7,
        FIF_PROBE_REQ           = 1<<8,
        FIF_MCAST_ACTION        = 1<<9,
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
 *
 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
 *
 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
 *
 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
 *      call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
 *      call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
 *      %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
 *      ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
 *      status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
 *      queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
 *      driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
 *      called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
 *      ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
 *      session is gone and removes the station.
 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
 *      but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
 *      now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
 *      should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
 */
enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
        IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
        IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
        IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
        IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
        IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
        IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
        IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
};

#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2

/**
 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
 *
 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
 * @tid: tid of the BA session
 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
 *      action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
 *      actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
 *      action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
 *      %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
 *      valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
 *      %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
 */
struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
        enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
        struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
        u16 tid;
        u16 ssn;
        u16 buf_size;
        bool amsdu;
        u16 timeout;
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
 *      frame received on trigger-enabled AC
 */
enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
        IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
        IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
 *
 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
 *      to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
 *      information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
 *      flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
 *      changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
 *      the peer.
 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
 *      by the peer
 */
enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
        IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED         = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED       = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
        IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED        = BIT(3),
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
 *
 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
 *      for sending management frames offchannel.
 */
enum ieee80211_roc_type {
        IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
        IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
 *
 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
 * reconfiguration type was completed.
 *
 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
 *      (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
 *      of wowlan configuration)
 */
enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
        IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
        IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
 *      only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
 *      used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
 *      valid for auth and (re)assoc.
 * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
 *      while just having been associated
 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
 *      0 for a non-MLO connection.
 */
struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
        u16 duration;
        u16 subtype;
        u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
        int link_id;
};

/**
 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
 *
 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
 *
 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
 *      skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
 *      The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
 *      configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
 *      preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
 *      Must be atomic.
 *
 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
 *      is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
 *      frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
 *      Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
 *      or zero.
 *      When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
 *      to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
 *      is added.
 *      Must be implemented and can sleep.
 *
 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
 *      is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
 *      it must turn off frame reception.)
 *      May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
 *      an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
 *      you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
 *      Must be implemented and can sleep.
 *
 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
 *      stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
 *      ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
 *      configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
 *      reconfigured at resume time.
 *      The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
 *      wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
 *      supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
 *      must return 1 from this function.
 *
 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
 *      now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
 *      functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
 *      to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
 *      will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
 *
 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
 *      modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
 *      supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
 *      in suspend().
 *
 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
 *      enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
 *      and @stop must be implemented.
 *      The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
 *      the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
 *      interface is given in the conf parameter.
 *      The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
 *      negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
 *      Must be implemented and can sleep.
 *
 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
 *      is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
 *      switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
 *      Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
 *      found by the interface iteration callbacks.
 *
 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
 *      The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
 *      and no monitor interfaces are present.
 *      When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
 *      must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
 *      the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
 *      MAC address of the device going away.
 *      Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
 *
 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
 *      function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
 *      This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
 *      if it does. The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
 *      parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
 *      level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
 *      This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
 *      for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
 *      of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
 *      can sleep.
 *      Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
 *      are not implemented.
 *
 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
 *      (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
 *      lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
 *      The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
 *      parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
 *      individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
 *      The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
 *      parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
 *      non-MLO connections.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
 *      This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
 *      to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
 *
 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
 *      See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
 *      This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
 *
 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
 *      This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
 *      should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
 *      of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
 *      which flags are changed.
 *      This callback can sleep.
 *
 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
 *      must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
 *
 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
 *      This callback is only called between add_interface and
 *      remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
 *      is enabled.
 *      Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
 *      This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
 *      which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
 *      The callback must be atomic.
 *
 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
 *      host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
 *      necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
 *      After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
 *      userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
 *
 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
 *      WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
 *      offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
 *
 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
 *      the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
 *      configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
 *      registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
 *      that power save is disabled.
 *      The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
 *      entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
 *      at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
 *      (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
 *      When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
 *      note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
 *      any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
 *      This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
 *      this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
 *      software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
 *      capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
 *      advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
 *      The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
 *      but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
 *      ieee80211_scan_completed().
 *      This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
 *      scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
 *      specific intervals.  The driver must call the
 *      ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
 *      This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
 *
 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
 *      In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
 *
 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
 *      is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
 *      The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
 *      the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
 *      can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
 *      software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
 *      this notification.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
 *      Returns zero if statistics are available.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
 *      IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
 *      IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
 *      The callback must be atomic.
 *
 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
 *      if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
 *      stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
 *      should be set as well.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
 *      AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
 *
 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
 *      station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
 *      returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
 *      no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
 *      the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
 *      This callback can sleep.
 *
 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
 *      directory with its files. This callback should be within a
 *      CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
 *
 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
 *      when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
 *      a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
 *      For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
 *      with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
 *
 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
 *      when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
 *      should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
 *      callback can sleep.
 *
 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
 *      when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
 *      should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
 *      callback can sleep.
 *      For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
 *      station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
 *
 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
 *      associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
 *      in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
 *      %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
 *
 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
 *      power for the station.
 *      This callback can sleep.
 *
 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
 *      station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
 *      This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
 *      It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
 *      up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
 *      isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
 *      period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
 *      See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
 *      synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
 *      pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
 *      the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
 *      in @sta_state.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
 *      be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
 *      from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
 *      in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
 *      uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
 *      otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
 *      Must be atomic.
 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
 *      is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
 *      the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
 *
 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
 *      filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
 *      let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
 *      the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
 *      all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
 *      Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @link_sta_statistics: Get link statistics for this station. For example with
 *      beacon filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be
 *      accurate, so let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can
 *      fill most of the values (indicating which by setting the filled
 *      bitmap), but not all of them make sense - see the source for which
 *      ones are possible.
 *      Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
 *      bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
 *      Returns a negative error code on failure.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
 *      this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
 *      required function.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
 *      Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
 *      required function.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
 *      firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
 *      calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
 *      as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
 *      with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
 *      function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
 *      TSF synchronization.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
 *      This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
 *      used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
 *      Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
 *
 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
 *      need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
 *      and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
 *      in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
 *      accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
 *      estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
 *      coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
 *
 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
 *      be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
 *      that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
 *      of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
 *      use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
 *      If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
 *      Note that vif can be NULL.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
 *      the given station, as it's about to be removed.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 *
 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
 *      switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
 *      callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
 *      completion of the channel switch.
 *
 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
 *      Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
 *      reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
 *      (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
 *
 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
 *
 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
 *      call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
 *      that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
 *      offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
 *      normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
 *      duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
 *      ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
 *      Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
 *      must be accepted in this case.
 *      This callback may sleep.
 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
 *      aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
 *
 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
 *
 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
 *
 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
 *      queues before entering power save.
 *
 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
 *      when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
 *      The callback can sleep.
 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
 *      &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
 *      The callback must be atomic.
 *
 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
 *      parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
 *      sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
 *      to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
 *      Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
 *      if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
 *      the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
 *      the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
 *      more-data bit must always be set.
 *      The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
 *      from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
 *      In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
 *      @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
 *      this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
 *      on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
 *      period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
 *      responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
 *      In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
 *      bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
 *      at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
 *      setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
 *      service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
 *      on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
 *      ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
 *      This callback must be atomic.
 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
 *      to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
 *      via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
 *      released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
 *      and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
 *      frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
 *      them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
 *      on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
 *      bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
 *      ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
 *      The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
 *      frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
 *      This callback must be atomic.
 *
 * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
 *      Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
 *      expected to return a static value.
 *
 * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
 *
 * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
 *      and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
 *      Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
 *      expected to return a static value.
 *
 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
 *      before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
 *      bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
 *      yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
 *      transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
 *      powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
 *      management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
 *      to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
 *      able to synchronize with the GO.
 *      The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
 *      mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
 *      Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
 *      data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
 *      driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
 *      The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
 *      transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
 *      is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
 *      Note that this isn't always called for each mgd_prepare_tx() call, for
 *      example for SAE the 'confirm' messages can be on the air in any order.
 *
 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
 *      a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
 *      channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
 *      setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
 *      mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
 *      discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
 *      2 * (DTIM period).
 *      The callback is optional and can sleep.
 *
 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
 *      This callback may sleep.
 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
 *      This callback may sleep.
 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
 *      may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
 *      channel context with different settings
 *      This callback may sleep.
 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
 *      to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
 *      This callback may sleep.
 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
 *      unbound from vif.
 *      This callback may sleep.
 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
 *      another, as specified in the list of
 *      @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
 *      to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
 *      This callback may sleep.
 *
 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
 *      information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
 *      context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
 *      software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
 *      just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
 *      disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
 *
 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
 *      during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
 *      This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
 *      indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
 *      This callback may sleep.
 *
 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
 *      Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
 *      This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
 *
 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
 *      Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
 *      function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
 *      decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
 *      ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
 *      get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
 *      1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
 *      transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
 *      If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
 *      since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
 *      before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
 *      gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
 *      the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
 *      after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
 *      driver to go back to a normal configuration.
 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
 *      when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
 *      driver to go back to a normal configuration.
 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
 *      when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
 *      CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
 *      information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
 *      channel context is bound before this is called.
 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
 *
 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
 *      specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
 *      if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
 *
 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
 *      and hardware limits.
 *
 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
 *      is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
 *      and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
 *      driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
 *      the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
 *      The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
 *      optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
 *      peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
 *      response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
 *      parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
 *      an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
 *      response template is provided, together with the location of the
 *      switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
 *      the function call.
 *
 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
 *      synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
 *      pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
 *      currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
 *
 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
 *      contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
 *      are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
 *      The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
 *      some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
 *      changed parameters.
 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
 *      cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
 *      this call.
 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
 *      ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
 *      NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
 *      aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
 *      between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
 *      skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
 *      Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
 *
 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
 *      This callback may sleep.
 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
 *      This callback may sleep.
 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
 *      4-address mode
 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
 *      to use rx decapsulation offload
 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
 *      This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
 *      are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
 *      The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
 *      twt structure.
 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
 *      from the peer.
 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
 *      radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
 *      or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
 *      Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
 *      switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
 *      radar channel.
 *      The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
 *      disable background CAC/radar detection.
 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
 *      resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
 *      supported by the driver.
 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
 *      removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
 *      but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
 *      new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
 *      The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
 *      that were already removed, in case they're needed.
 *      Note that removal of link should always succeed, so the return value
 *      will be ignored in a removal only case.
 *      This callback can sleep.
 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
 *      @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
 *      Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
 *      i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
 *      In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
 *      not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
 *      that.
 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
 *      flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
 *      Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
 *      at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
 *      if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
 *      If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
 *      modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
 * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
 *      drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
 *      the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
 *      interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
 *      implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
 *      &enum nl80211_iftype.
 * @set_eml_op_mode: Configure eMLSR/eMLMR operation mode in the underlay
 *      driver according to the parameter received in the EML Operating mode
 *      notification frame.
 */
struct ieee80211_ops {
        void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
                   struct sk_buff *skb);
        int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
        void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
#ifdef CONFIG_PM
        int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
        int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
        void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
#endif
        int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                             struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
        void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx, u32 changed);
        void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
                                 u64 changed);
        void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                u64 changed);
        void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
                                  u64 changed);

        int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                        struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
        void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                        struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);

        u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
        void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 unsigned int changed_flags,
                                 unsigned int *total_flags,
                                 u64 multicast);
        void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                    unsigned int filter_flags,
                                    unsigned int changed_flags);
        int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                       bool set);
        int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
                       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
        void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
                                struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
        void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                               struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
        void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                        struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
        int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
        void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
                                struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
        int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                              const u8 *mac_addr);
        void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                         struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
        void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                            struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
                            struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
        int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
                                  u32 value);
        int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
                                 u32 value);
        int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
        int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                          struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
        void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
                                 struct dentry *dir);
        void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                struct dentry *dir);
        void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
                                     struct dentry *dir);
#endif
        void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                        enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
        int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                             struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                             struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
        int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                         struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                         enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
                         enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
        void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
        void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                   struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
                                   u32 changed);
        void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
        void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                               struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                               struct station_info *sinfo);
        int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
                       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
        u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                        u64 tsf);
        void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                           s64 offset);
        void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
        void (*link_sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                    struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
                                    struct link_station_info *link_sinfo);

        /**
         * @ampdu_action:
         * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
         * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
         * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
         * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
         * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
         * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
         * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
         * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
         * possible with a buf_size of 8:
         *
         * - ``TX: 1.....7``
         * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
         * - ``TX:        8..1...``
         *
         * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
         * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
         *
         * - ``TX:        1   or``
         * - ``TX:        18  or``
         * - ``TX:        81``
         *
         * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
         *
         * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
         * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
         * if the session can start immediately.
         *
         * The callback can sleep.
         */
        int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                            struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                            struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
        int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
                struct survey_info *survey);
        void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
        void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
                                   s16 coverage_class);
#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
        int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                            void *data, int len);
        int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
                             struct netlink_callback *cb,
                             void *data, int len);
#endif
        void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                      u32 queues, bool drop);
        void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                          struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
        void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                               struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
        int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
                           u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
        int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
                           u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);

        int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
                                 int duration,
                                 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
        int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                        struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
        void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
        bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
        int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
        void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                               const struct ieee80211_event *event);

        void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                      u16 tids, int num_frames,
                                      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
                                      bool more_data);
        void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                        struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                        u16 tids, int num_frames,
                                        enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
                                        bool more_data);

        int     (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
        void    (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
        void    (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                  u32 sset, u8 *data);

        void    (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
        void    (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);

        void    (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                             struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                             unsigned int link_id);

        int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                           struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
        void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
        void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
                               u32 changed);
        int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
                                  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
        void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
                                     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
        int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
                                  int n_vifs,
                                  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);

        void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);

#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
        void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                 struct inet6_dev *idev);
#endif
        void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
        int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);

        int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
        void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
        void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                         struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                         struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);

        int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
        int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                           unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);

        int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
                                   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
                                   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
        void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                           struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                           struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
        void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                         struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                         struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);

        void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
        void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

        int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                         struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                         struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
        int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                        struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                               struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
        int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                            struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                            const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
        void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                            struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                            u8 instance_id);
        bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                       struct sk_buff *head,
                                       struct sk_buff *skb);
        int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
        int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                          struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
        void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                           struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
        int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                              struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                              struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
        int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
        void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
        void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                              struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
        int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                             const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
        void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
        void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                              struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
        void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
        int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
        int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
                                     struct net_device_path *path);
        bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                   u16 active_links);
        int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
                                struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
        int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
        int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
        int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                            struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                            struct net_device *dev,
                            enum tc_setup_type type,
                            void *type_data);
        enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
        (*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                        struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
        void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   enum nl80211_iftype type);
        int (*set_eml_op_mode)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                               struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                               struct ieee80211_eml_params *eml_params);
};

/**
 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
 *
 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
 * @priv_data_len.
 *
 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
 * @ops: callbacks for this device
 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
 *      NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
 *
 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
 */
struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
                                           const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
                                           const char *requested_name);

/**
 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
 *
 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
 * @priv_data_len.
 *
 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
 * @ops: callbacks for this device
 *
 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
 */
static inline
struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
                                        const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
{
        return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
 *
 * You must call this function before any other functions in
 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
 *
 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 *
 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
 */
int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
 *      (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
 */
struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
        int throughput;
        int blink_time;
};

/**
 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
 *      interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
 */
enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
        IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO          = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK           = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED      = BIT(2),
};

#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
const char *
__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   unsigned int flags,
                                   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
                                   unsigned int blink_table_len);
#endif
/**
 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
 *
 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 *
 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
 */
static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
{
#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
        return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
#else
        return NULL;
#endif
}

/**
 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
 *
 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 *
 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
 */
static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
{
#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
        return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
#else
        return NULL;
#endif
}

/**
 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
 *
 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 *
 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
 */
static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
{
#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
        return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
#else
        return NULL;
#endif
}

/**
 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
 *
 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 *
 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
 */
static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
{
#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
        return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
#else
        return NULL;
#endif
}

/**
 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
 *
 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
 *
 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
 */
static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
                                 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
                                 unsigned int blink_table_len)
{
#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
        return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
                                                  blink_table_len);
#else
        return NULL;
#endif
}

/**
 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
 *
 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
 */
void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
 *
 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
 * before calling this function.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware to free
 */
void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
 *
 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware to restart
 */
void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
 *
 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
 *
 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
 *
 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
 *
 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
 * @list: the destination list
 */
void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);

/**
 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
 *
 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
 *
 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
 *
 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
 * @napi: the NAPI context
 */
void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);

/**
 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
 *
 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
 *
 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
 *
 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
 *
 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
 */
static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
{
        ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
 *
 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
 *
 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
 *
 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
 */
void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);

/**
 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
 *
 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
 * (internally disables bottom halves).
 *
 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
 *
 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
 */
static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                   struct sk_buff *skb)
{
        local_bh_disable();
        ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
        local_bh_enable();
}

/**
 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
 *
 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
 * entering/leaving PS mode.
 *
 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
 *
 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
 * each other.
 *
 * @sta: currently connected sta
 * @start: start or stop PS
 *
 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
 */
int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);

/**
 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
 *                                  (in process context)
 *
 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
 * applies.
 *
 * @sta: currently connected sta
 * @start: start or stop PS
 *
 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
 */
static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                                  bool start)
{
        int ret;

        local_bh_disable();
        ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
        local_bh_enable();

        return ret;
}

/**
 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
 * @sta: currently connected station
 *
 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
 * connected station was received.
 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
 * be serialized.
 */
void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);

/**
 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
 * @sta: currently connected station
 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
 *
 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
 * from a connected station was received.
 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
 * serialized.
 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
 * checks.
 */
void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);

/*
 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
 */
#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM    ALIGN(14, 4)

/**
 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
 *
 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
 *
 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
 * call! Beware of the locking!)
 *
 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
 *
 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
 * use this API.
 */
void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                u8 tid, bool buffered);

/**
 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
 *
 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
 * rate selection table for the station entry.
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
 */
void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                            struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                            struct sk_buff *skb,
                            struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
                            int max_rates);

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
 *
 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
 * @info: tx status information
 */
void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
                              struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
 *
 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
 *
 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
 *
 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
 */
void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                             struct sk_buff *skb);

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
 *
 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
 *
 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
 * @status: tx status information
 */
void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                             struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
 *
 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
 * specific skbs.
 *
 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
 *      (NULL for multicast packets)
 * @info: tx status information
 */
static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                             struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                             struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
{
        struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
                .sta = sta,
                .info = info,
        };

        ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
 *
 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
 *
 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
 * for a single hardware.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
 */
static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                          struct sk_buff *skb)
{
        local_bh_disable();
        ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
        local_bh_enable();
}

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
 *
 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
 *
 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
 */
void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 struct sk_buff *skb);

/**
 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
 *
 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
 * connected STA.
 *
 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
 */
void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);

#define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2

/**
 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
 *      to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
 *      should be ignored.
 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
 */
struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
        u16 tim_offset;
        u16 tim_length;

        u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
        u16 mbssid_off;
};

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
 *      receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
 *      that is not associated with AP MLD).
 *
 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
 * obtain the beacon template.
 *
 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
 * applicable, the CSA count.
 *
 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
 *
 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
 */
struct sk_buff *
ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                              struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
                              unsigned int link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
 *      receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
 *
 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
 * requested index.
 *
 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
 */
struct sk_buff *
ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                        struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                        struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
                                        unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);

/**
 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
 *
 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
 *      receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
 */
struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
        u8 cnt;
        struct {
                struct sk_buff *skb;
                struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
        } bcn[];
};

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
 *
 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
 * one multiple BSSID element.
 *
 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
 *
 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
 *      %NULL on error.
 */
struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                       unsigned int link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
 *
 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
 */
void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
 *      Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
 *      (including the ID and length bytes!).
 *      Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
 *      that is not associated with AP MLD).
 *
 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
 * obtain the beacon frame.
 *
 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
 *
 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
 *
 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
 */
struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                         struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                         u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
                                         unsigned int link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
 *      that is not associated with AP MLD).
 *
 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
 *
 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
 */
static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                                   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                                   unsigned int link_id)
{
        return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
 *
 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
 * This function is called implicitly when
 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
 *
 * Return: new countdown value
 */
u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                  unsigned int link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @counter: the new value for the counter
 *
 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
 *
 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
 */
void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);

/**
 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
 *
 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
 */
void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
 *
 * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
 */
bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                         unsigned int link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
 *
 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
 */
void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
 *
 * Can only be called in AP mode.
 *
 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
 */
struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                        struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
 *
 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
 *
 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
 */
struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
 *      for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
 *      MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
 *      if at all possible
 *
 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
 * BSSID and address is used.
 *
 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
 *
 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
 *
 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
 */
struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                       int link_id, bool qos_ok);

/**
 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @src_addr: source MAC address
 * @ssid: SSID buffer
 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
 *
 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
 * hardware.
 *
 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
 */
struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                       const u8 *src_addr,
                                       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
                                       size_t tailroom);

/**
 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
 *
 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
 */
void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
                       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
                       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);

/**
 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
 *
 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
 *
 * Return: The duration.
 */
__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
                              const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);

/**
 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
 *
 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
 */
void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                             struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                             const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
                             const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
                             struct ieee80211_cts *cts);

/**
 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
 *
 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
 *
 * Return: The duration.
 */
__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                    size_t frame_len,
                                    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);

/**
 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
 *
 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
 *
 * Return: The duration.
 */
__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                        struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                        enum nl80211_band band,
                                        size_t frame_len,
                                        struct ieee80211_rate *rate);

/**
 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
 *
 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
 * frames are available.
 *
 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
 * use common code for all beacons.
 */
struct sk_buff *
ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
 *
 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
 *
 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
 */
void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
                               u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);

/**
 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
 *
 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
 * from the given packet.
 *
 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
 *      with this P1K
 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
 */
static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
                                          struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
{
        struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
        const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
        u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);

        ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
 *
 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
 * and transmitter address.
 *
 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
 */
void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
                               const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);

/**
 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
 *
 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
 * in the packet.
 *
 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
 *      encrypted with this key
 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
 */
void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
                            struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);

/**
 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
 *
 * @pos: start of crypto header
 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
 * @pn: PN to add
 *
 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
 * the packet payload)
 *
 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
 * point to the crypto header)
 */
u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);

/**
 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
 *
 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
 *      the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
 *      CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
 *
 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
 * by the device and not by mac80211.
 *
 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
 * can be done concurrently.
 */
void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
                              int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);

/**
 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
 *
 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
 *      the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
 *      CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
 * @seq: new sequence data
 *
 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
 *
 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
 * can be done concurrently.
 */
void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
                              int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);

/**
 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
 * @idx: the keyidx of the key
 * @key_data: the key data
 * @key_len: the key data. Might be bigger than the actual key length,
 *      but not smaller (for the driver convinence)
 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
 *
 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
 *
 * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
 * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
 *
 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
 * of the reconfiguration.
 *
 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
 *
 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call.
 */
struct ieee80211_key_conf *
ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                        u8 idx, u8 *key_data, u8 key_len,
                        int link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
 * @gfp: allocation flags
 */
void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
                                const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);

/**
 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
 *
 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
 * at the same time.
 *
 * @keyconf: the key in question
 */
void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);

/**
 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
 *
 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
 * at the same time.
 *
 * @keyconf: the key in question
 */
void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);

/**
 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
 *
 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
 */
void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);

/**
 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
 *
 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
 */
void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);

/**
 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
 *
 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
 *
 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
 */

int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);

/**
 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 *
 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
 */
void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 *
 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
 */
void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
 *
 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
 * any context, including hardirq context.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
 * @info: information about the completed scan
 */
void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);

/**
 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
 *
 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
 */
void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
 *
 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
 * while associating, for instance.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
 */
void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
 *      been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
 *      reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
 *      interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
 *      haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
 *      interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
 *      is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
 *      for instance.
 */
enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
        IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL     = 0,
        IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
        IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE     = BIT(1),
        IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER        = BIT(2),
};

/**
 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
 *
 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
 *
 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
 */
void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
                                  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
                                                   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
                                  void *data);

/**
 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
 *
 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
 * be used.
 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
 *
 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
 */
static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
                                    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
                                                     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
                                    void *data)
{
        ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
                                     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
                                     iterator, data);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
 *
 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
 *
 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
 */
void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                                u32 iter_flags,
                                                void (*iterator)(void *data,
                                                    u8 *mac,
                                                    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
                                                void *data);

struct ieee80211_vif *
__ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *prev,
                               u32 iter_flags);

/**
 * for_each_interface - iterate interfaces under wiphy mutex
 * @vif: the iterator variable
 * @hw: the HW to iterate for
 * @flags: the iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
 */
#define for_each_interface(vif, hw, flags)                              \
        for (vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, NULL, flags);     \
             vif;                                                       \
             vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, vif, flags))

/**
 * for_each_active_interface - iterate active interfaces under wiphy mutex
 * @vif: the iterator variable
 * @hw: the HW to iterate for
 */
#define for_each_active_interface(vif, hw)                              \
        for_each_interface(vif, hw, IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)

/**
 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
 *
 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
 */
static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                        u32 iter_flags,
                                        void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
                                                         struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
                                        void *data)
{
        struct ieee80211_vif *vif;

        for_each_interface(vif, hw, iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)
                iterator(data, vif->addr, vif);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
 *
 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
 * function for them.
 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
 *
 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
 */
void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                       void (*iterator)(void *data,
                                                struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
                                       void *data);

struct ieee80211_sta *
__ieee80211_iterate_stations(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                             struct ieee80211_sta *prev);

/**
 * for_each_station - iterate stations under wiphy mutex
 * @sta: the iterator variable
 * @hw: the HW to iterate for
 */
#define for_each_station(sta, hw)                                       \
        for (sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, NULL);              \
             sta;                                                       \
             sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, sta))

/**
 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
 *
 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
 * mutex.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
 */
static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               void (*iterator)(void *data,
                                                struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
                               void *data)
{
        struct ieee80211_sta *sta;

        for_each_station(sta, hw)
                iterator(data, sta);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
 *
 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
 */
void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);

/**
 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
 *
 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
 * workqueue.
 *
 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
 */
void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                  struct delayed_work *dwork,
                                  unsigned long delay);

/**
 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
 *
 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
 * mac80211.
 *
 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
 */
void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                            u16 tid);

/**
 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
 *
 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
 *
 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
 * will be managed by the mac80211.
 */
int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
                                  u16 timeout);

/**
 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
 *
 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
 * from any context.
 */
void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
                                      u16 tid);

/**
 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
 *
 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
 *
 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
 * will be managed by the mac80211.
 */
int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);

/**
 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
 *
 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
 * can be called from any context.
 */
void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
                                     u16 tid);

/**
 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
 *
 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
 * @addr: station's address
 *
 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
 *
 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
 */
struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                         const u8 *addr);

/**
 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @addr: remote station's address
 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
 *
 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
 *
 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
 *
 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
 *      is not reliable.
 *
 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
 */
struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                               const u8 *addr,
                                               const u8 *localaddr);

/**
 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @addr: remote station's link address
 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
 *      may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
 *
 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
 *
 * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
 */
struct ieee80211_sta *
ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                 const u8 *addr,
                                 const u8 *localaddr,
                                 unsigned int *link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
 * @hw: the hardware
 * @pubsta: the station
 * @block: whether to block or unblock
 *
 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
 *
 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
 * manner.
 *
 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
 * woke up while blocked or not.
 */
void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                               struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);

/**
 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
 * @pubsta: the station
 *
 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
 *
 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
 *
 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
 *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
 *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
 *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
 */
void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);

/**
 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
 * @pubsta: the station
 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
 *
 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
 */
void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);

/**
 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
 * @pubsta: the station
 *
 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
 *
 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
 * there is no need to call this function.
 */
void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);

/**
 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
 *
 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
 *
 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
 * attempts.
 *
 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
 * them to 0.
 *
 * @pubsta: the station
 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
 */
void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
                                    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);

/**
 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
 *
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
 *
 * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
 */
bool
ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);

/**
 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
 *
 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
 *
 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
 *
 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
 * set_key callback.
 */
void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                         struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                         void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
                                      void *data),
                         void *iter_data);

/**
 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
 *
 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
 * in removal process will be skipped.
 *
 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
 * and thus iter must be atomic.
 */
void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                             struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                             void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                          struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                          struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                          struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
                                          void *data),
                             void *iter_data);

/**
 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @iter: iterator function
 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
 *
 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
 * places while calling into the driver.
 *
 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
 * removed.
 *
 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
 * or not.
 */
void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
        struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
        void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
                     void *data),
        void *iter_data);

/**
 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx - iterate channel contexts
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @iter: iterator function
 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
 *
 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function can only be used while
 * holding the wiphy mutex.
 *
 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
 * removed.
 *
 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
 * or not.
 */
void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx(
        struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
        void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
                     void *data),
        void *iter_data);

/**
 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
 * information. This function must only be called from within the
 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
 * %NULL.
 *
 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
 */
struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                          struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
 */
void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
 *
 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
 * without connection recovery attempts.
 */
void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
 *
 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
 */
void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);

/**
 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
 *
 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
 * disconnect normally later.
 *
 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
 */
void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
 * hardware restart
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
 * hardware restart.
 */
void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
 *      rssi threshold triggered
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
 * @gfp: context flags
 *
 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
 */
void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                               enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
                               s32 rssi_level,
                               gfp_t gfp);

/**
 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @gfp: context flags
 */
void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);

/**
 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
 *      pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
 */
void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);

/**
 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
 *      false.
 *
 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
 * and wake up the suspended queues.
 */
void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
                             unsigned int link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
 * a deauth frame in this case.
 */
void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
 *
 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
 */
void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
                            enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);

/**
 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 */
void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 */
void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);

/**
 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
 *
 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
 */
void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
                                  const u8 *addr);

/**
 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
 * @pubsta: station struct
 * @tid: the session's TID
 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
 *      assumed to be out of the window after the call
 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
 *
 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
 */
void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
                                          u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
                                          u16 received_mpdus);

/**
 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
 *
 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
 * buffer.
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @ra: the peer's destination address
 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
 */
void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);

/**
 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
 * @addr: station mac address
 * @tid: the rx tid
 */
void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
                                 unsigned int tid);

/**
 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
 *
 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
 * reordering.
 *
 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
 * @addr: station mac address
 * @tid: the rx tid
 */
static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                                      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
{
        if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
                return;
        ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
 *
 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
 * reordering.
 *
 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
 * @addr: station mac address
 * @tid: the rx tid
 */
static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                                     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
{
        if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
                return;
        ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
 *
 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
 *
 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
 * @addr: station mac address
 * @tid: the rx tid
 */
void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);

/* Rate control API */

/**
 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
 *
 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
 *      to be filled in
 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
 *      which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
 *      used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
 *      RTS threshold
 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
 *      if the selected rate supports it
 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
 */
struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
        struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
        struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
        struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
        struct sk_buff *skb;
        struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
        bool rts, short_preamble;
        u32 rate_idx_mask;
        u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
        bool bss;
};

/**
 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
 */
enum rate_control_capabilities {
        /**
         * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
         * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
         * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
         * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
         * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
         */
        RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
        /**
         * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
         * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
         */
        RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
};

struct rate_control_ops {
        unsigned long capa;
        const char *name;
        void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
        void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
                            struct dentry *debugfsdir);
        void (*free)(void *priv);

        void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
        void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                          struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
                          struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
        void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                            struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
                            struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
                            u32 changed);
        void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                         void *priv_sta);

        void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
                              struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                              void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
        void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                          struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
                          struct sk_buff *skb);
        void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
                         struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);

        void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
                                struct dentry *dir);

        u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
};

static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
                                 enum nl80211_band band,
                                 int index)
{
        return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
}

static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
{
        int i;

        for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
                if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
                        return i;

        /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
        WARN_ON_ONCE(1);

        /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
        return 0;
}

static inline
bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                              struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
{
        unsigned int i;

        for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
                if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
                        return true;
        return false;
}

/**
 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
 *
 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
 * the most recent rate control module decision.
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
 *
 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
 */
int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                           struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
                           struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);

int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);

static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
{
        return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
}

static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
{
        return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
               conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
}

static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
{
        return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
               conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
}

static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
{
        return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
}

static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
{
        return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
                (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
                (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
}

static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
{
        if (p2p) {
                switch (type) {
                case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
                        return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
                case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
                        return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
                default:
                        break;
                }
        }
        return type;
}

static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
{
        return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
 *
 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
 */
static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                                struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
{
        return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
}

/**
 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
 *
 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
 */
static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                               struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
{
        return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
}

/**
 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return EHT capabilities for sband/vif
 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
 *
 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
 */
static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                                 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
{
        return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
}

/**
 * ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif - return UHR capabilities for sband/vif
 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
 *
 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap, or %NULL is none found
 */
static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap *
ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
                                 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
{
        return ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
}

/**
 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
 *
 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 *
 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
 * matching GroupId management frame.
 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
 */
void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
                                const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);

void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                   int rssi_min_thold,
                                   int rssi_max_thold);

void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
 *
 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO
 *
 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
 *
 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
 * applicable.
 */
int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
 * @vif: virtual interface
 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
 * @gfp: allocation flags
 *
 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
 */
void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
                                    gfp_t gfp);

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @vif: virtual interface
 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
 * @band: the band to transmit on
 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
 *
 * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise.
 * On failure, the skb is freed by this function; callers must not
 * free it again.
 *
 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
 */
bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
                              int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);

/**
 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
 *                               of injected frames.
 *
 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
 * of the skb before calling this function.
 *
 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
 *
 * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
 */
bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
                                 struct net_device *dev);

/**
 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
 *
 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
 *
 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
 *
 * private:
 *
 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
 */
struct ieee80211_noa_data {
        u32 next_tsf;
        bool has_next_tsf;

        u8 absent;

        u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
        struct {
                u32 start;
                u32 duration;
                u32 interval;
        } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
};

/**
 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
 *
 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
 * @data: NoA tracking data
 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
 *
 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
 */
int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
                            struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);

/**
 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
 *
 * @data: NoA tracking data
 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
 */
void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);

/**
 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
 * @vif: virtual interface
 * @peer: the peer's destination address
 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
 * @gfp: allocation flags
 *
 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
 */
void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
                                 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
                                 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);

/**
 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
 *
 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
 *
 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
 *
 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
 * @tid: the TID to reserve
 *
 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
 */
int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);

/**
 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
 *
 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
 *
 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
 *
 * @sta: the station
 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
 */
void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
 *      ieee80211_next_txq()
 *
 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
 *
 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
 *
 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
 */
struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);

/**
 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
 * (in process context)
 *
 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
 * (internally disables bottom halves).
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
 *      ieee80211_next_txq()
 *
 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
 */
static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                                      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
{
        struct sk_buff *skb;

        local_bh_disable();
        skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
        local_bh_enable();

        return skb;
}

/**
 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
 *
 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
 */
void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);

/**
 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
 *
 * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
 * driver has finished scheduling it.
 */
struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);

/**
 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
 *
 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
 */
void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);

/* (deprecated) */
static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
{
}

void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);

/**
 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
 *
 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
 *
 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
 * this TXQ internally.
 */
static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
{
        __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
 *
 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
 * internally.
 */
static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
                     bool force)
{
        __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
 *
 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
 * next_txq().
 *
 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
 * again.
 *
 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
 *
 * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
 */
bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                struct ieee80211_txq *txq);

/**
 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
 *
 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
 *
 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
 */
void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
                             unsigned long *frame_cnt,
                             unsigned long *byte_cnt);

/**
 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
 *
 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @inst_id: the local instance id
 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
 * @gfp: allocation flags
 */
void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                   u8 inst_id,
                                   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
                                   gfp_t gfp);

/**
 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
 *
 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @match: match event information
 * @gfp: allocation flags
 */
void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                              struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
                              gfp_t gfp);

/**
 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
 *
 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
 *          information.
 * @len: frame length in bytes
 *
 * Return: the airtime estimate
 */
u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
                              int len);

/**
 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
 *
 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
 *
 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
 * @len: frame length in bytes
 *
 * Return: the airtime estimate
 */
u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                              struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
                              int len);
/**
 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
 *
 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
 */
struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                                  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
 *      probe response template.
 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 *
 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
 *
 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
 */
struct sk_buff *
ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                          struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
 * collision.
 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
 *
 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
 *      aware of.
 */
void
ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);

/**
 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
 *
 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
 *
 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
 *
 * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
 */
static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
{
        struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
        struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;

        return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
               ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
}

/**
 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
 * @vif: interface to set active links on
 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
 *
 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
 *      back into the driver.
 *
 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
 *
 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
 * a sequence of calls like
 *
 *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
 *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
 *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
 *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
 *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
 *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
 *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
 *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
 *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
 *
 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
 */
int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);

/**
 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
 * @vif: interface to set active links on
 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
 *
 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
 * completed after it returns.
 */
void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
                                      u16 active_links);

/**
 * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
 * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
 *
 * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
 * TTLM request.
 */
void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);

/**
 * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
 * @width: the channel width value to convert
 * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
 */
static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
{
        switch (width) {
        default:
                WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
                fallthrough;
        case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
        case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
                return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
        case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
                return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
        case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
                return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
        case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
        case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
                return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
        case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
                return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
        }
}

/**
 * ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw - prepare for sending BW RX OMI
 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI is going to be sent to
 * @bw: the bandwidth requested
 *
 * When the driver decides to do RX OMI to change bandwidth with a STA
 * it calls this function to prepare, then sends the OMI, and finally
 * calls ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw().
 *
 * Note that the (link) STA rate control is updated accordingly as well,
 * but the chanctx might not be updated if there are other users.
 * If the intention is to reduce the listen bandwidth, the driver must
 * ensure there are no TDLS stations nor other uses of the chanctx.
 *
 * Also note that in order to sequence correctly, narrowing bandwidth
 * will only happen in ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(), whereas widening
 * again (e.g. going back to normal) will happen here.
 *
 * Note that we treat this symmetrically, so if the driver calls this
 * and tells the peer to only send with a lower bandwidth, we assume
 * that the driver also wants to only send at that lower bandwidth, to
 * allow narrowing of the chanctx request for this station/interface.
 *
 * Finally, the driver must ensure that if the function returned %true,
 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw() is also called, even for example in
 * case of HW restart.
 *
 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held, and will call back
 *          into the driver, so ensure no driver locks are held.
 *
 * Return: %true if changes are going to be made, %false otherwise
 */
bool ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
                                 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bw);

/**
 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw - finalize BW RX OMI update
 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI was sent to
 *
 * See ieee80211_client_prepare_rx_omi_bw(). Context is the same here
 * as well.
 */
void ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta);

/* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
                                      u32 changed);
int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
                                         struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
                                         int n_vifs,
                                         enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);

/**
 * ieee80211_vif_nan_started - Return whether a NAN vif is started
 * @vif: the vif
 * Return: %true iff the vif is a NAN interface and NAN is started
 */
bool ieee80211_vif_nan_started(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
#endif /* MAC80211_H */